blob: 1c698da0537d4e4d6480ea89f2aa30d0a1a8601d [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000019#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000021#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000022#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000024#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000025#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000026#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
27#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000028#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000029#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000030#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000031#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000032using namespace clang;
33
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000034
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000035/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
36/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
37///
38/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
39/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
40/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
41/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
42/// function is being used.
43///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000044/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
45/// decls.
46///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000047/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
48/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000049///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000050bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000051 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000052 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000053 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000054 }
55
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000056 // See if the decl is unavailable
57 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
58 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
59 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
60 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000061
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000062 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000063 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000064 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
65 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
66 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
67 return true;
68 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000069 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000070
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000072}
73
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000074/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000075/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000076/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
77///
78void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000080 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000081 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000082 return;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000083 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
84 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000086 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
87 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000088 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000089 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
90 int isMethod = 0;
91 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
92 // skip over named parameters.
93 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
94 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
95 if (nullPos)
96 --nullPos;
97 else
98 ++i;
99 }
100 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
101 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000102 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000103 // skip over named parameters.
104 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
105 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
106 if (nullPos)
107 --nullPos;
108 else
109 ++i;
110 }
111 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000112 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000113 // block or function pointer call.
114 QualType Ty = V->getType();
115 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000116 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000117 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
118 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000119 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
120 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
121 unsigned k;
122 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
123 if (nullPos)
124 --nullPos;
125 else
126 ++i;
127 }
128 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
129 }
130 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
131 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000132 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000133 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000134 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000135 return;
136
137 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000138 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000140 return;
141 }
142 int sentinel = i;
143 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
144 --sentinelPos;
145 ++i;
146 }
147 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000150 return;
151 }
152 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
153 ++i;
154 ++sentinel;
155 }
156 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
Anders Carlssone4d2bdd2009-11-24 17:24:21 +0000157 if (sentinelExpr && (!isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr) &&
158 (!sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
159 !sentinelExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
160 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)))) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000161 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000162 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000163 }
164 return;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000165}
166
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000167SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
168 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
169 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
170}
171
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000172//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
173// Standard Promotions and Conversions
174//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
175
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000176/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
177void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
178 QualType Ty = E->getType();
179 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
180
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000181 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000182 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000183 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000184 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
185 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
186 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
187 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
188 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
189 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
190 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000191 //
192 // C++ 4.2p1:
193 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
194 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
195 //
196 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
197 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000198 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
199 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000200 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000201}
202
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000203void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
204 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000205
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000206 QualType Ty = E->getType();
207 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
208 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
209 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
210 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
211 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
212 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
213 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
214 // rvalue is T
215 //
216 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
218 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000219 // type of the lvalue.
220 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
221 }
222}
223
224
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000225/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000226/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000227/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
228/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
229/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
230Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
231 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
232 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000234 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
235 //
236 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
237 // unsigned int may be used:
238 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
239 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
240 // and unsigned int.
241 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
242 //
243 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
244 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
245 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
246 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000247 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
248 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000249 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000250 return Expr;
251 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000252 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000253 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000254 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000255 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000256 }
257
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000258 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000259 return Expr;
260}
261
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000262/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000263/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000264/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
265void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
266 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
267 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000268
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000269 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000270 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000271 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000272 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
273 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000274
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000275 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
276}
277
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000278/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
279/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
280/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
281/// completely illegal.
282bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000283 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000284
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000285 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCInterfaceType() &&
286 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
287 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
288 << Expr->getType() << CT))
289 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000290
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000291 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000292 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000293 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
294 << Expr->getType() << CT))
295 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000296
297 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000298}
299
300
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000301/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
302/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000303/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
305/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
306/// GCC.
307QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
308 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000309 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000310 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000311
312 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000313
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000314 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000315 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000316 QualType lhs =
317 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000319 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000320
321 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
322 if (lhs == rhs)
323 return lhs;
324
325 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
326 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
327 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
328 return lhs;
329
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000330 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000331 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000332 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
333 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000334 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000335 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
336 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
337
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000338 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000339 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000340 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
341 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000342 return destType;
343}
344
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000345//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
346// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
347//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
348
349
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000350/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000351/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
352/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
353/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
354/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000355///
356Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000357Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000358 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
359
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000360 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000361 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000362 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000363
364 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
365 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
366 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000367
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000368 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000369 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000370 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000371
372 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCall4b7a8342010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000373 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000374 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000375
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000376 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
377 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
378 // strings.
379 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000380 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000381 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000382
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000383 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000384 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000385 Literal.GetStringLength(),
386 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
387 &StringTokLocs[0],
388 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000389}
390
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000391/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
392/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
393/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
394/// for values inside the block or for globals).
395///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000396/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000397/// up-to-date.
398///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000399static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000400 ValueDecl *VD) {
401 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
402 // we wanted to.
403 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
404 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000405
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000406 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
407 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
408 return false;
409
410 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
411 // snapshot it.
412 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
413 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000414 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
415 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000416
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000417 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
418 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
419
420 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
421 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
422 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
423 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000424 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
425 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000426
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000427 if (!NextBlock)
428 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000429
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000430 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
431 // having a reference outside it.
432 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
433 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
436 // a snapshot as well.
437 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
438 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000439
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000440 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000441}
442
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000443
444
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000445/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000446Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000447Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000448 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000449 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
450 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000451 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000452 << D->getDeclName();
453 return ExprError();
454 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000455
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000456 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
457 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
458 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
459 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000460 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000461 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000463 << D->getIdentifier();
464 return ExprError();
465 }
466 }
467 }
468 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000470 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000471
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000472 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
473 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
474 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000475 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000476}
477
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000478/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
479/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
480/// is Record.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000481static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
482 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000484 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000485
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000486 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
487 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
488 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000489 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000491 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000492 D != DEnd; ++D) {
493 if (*D == Record) {
494 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
495 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
496 ++D;
497 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor4afa39d2009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000498 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000499 return *D;
500 }
501 }
502
503 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
504 return 0;
505}
506
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000507/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
508/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
509/// actual member.
510///
511/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
512/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
513/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
514/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
515/// we found.
516///
517/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
518/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
519/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
520VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
521 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000522 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
523 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
524 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
525
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000526 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
528 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
529 do {
530 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000531 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000534 else {
535 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
536 break;
537 }
538 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000539 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000540 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541
542 return BaseObject;
543}
544
545Sema::OwningExprResult
546Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
547 FieldDecl *Field,
548 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
549 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
550 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000551 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000552 AnonFields);
553
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000554 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
555 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
556 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
557 // found via name lookup.
558 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000560 if (BaseObject) {
561 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
562 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000563 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000564 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000565 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000566 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 BaseQuals
568 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000569 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
570 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
571 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
572 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
573 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000574 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
576 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
577 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000578 BaseQuals
579 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 } else {
581 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
582 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
583 // program our base object expression is "this".
584 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
585 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000586 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000587 = Context.getTagDeclType(
588 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
589 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000590 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
592 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
593 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000594 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000595 MD->getThisType(Context),
596 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
598 }
599 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000603 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000604 }
605
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000606 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000607 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
608 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 }
610
611 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
612 // anonymous struct/union.
613 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000614 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000615 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
616 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
617 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
618 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000619 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
620 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
621
622 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
623 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
624 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
625 ResultQuals.removeConst();
626
627 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
628 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
629
630 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
631 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
632
633 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
634 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
635 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
636
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000637 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000638 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000639 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000640 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
641 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000642 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000643 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000644 }
645
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000646 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000647}
648
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000649/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
650/// possibly a list of template arguments.
651///
652/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
653/// DecomposeTemplateName.
654///
655/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
656/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
657/// some way.
658static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
659 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
660 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
661 DeclarationName &Name,
662 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
664 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
665 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
666 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
667
668 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
669 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
670 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
671 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
672 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
673
674 TemplateName TName =
675 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
676
677 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
678 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
679 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
680 } else {
681 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
682 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
683 TemplateArgs = 0;
684 }
685}
686
687/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
688///
689/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
690/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
691/// found template arguments.
692static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
693 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
694 TemplateName TName =
695 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
696
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000697 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
698 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCall0bd6feb2009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000699 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
700 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
701 I != E; ++I)
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000702 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCallb681b612009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000703
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000704 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000705}
706
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000707/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
708/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
709/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000710static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000711 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
712 return false;
713
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000714 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
715 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
716 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
717 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
718 if (!BaseRT) return false;
719
720 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000721 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000722 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
723 return false;
724 }
725
726 return true;
727}
728
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000729/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
730/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
731static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000733
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000734 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
735 if (!DC) return true;
736
737 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
738 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
739
740 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
741 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
742
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000743 return false;
744}
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000745
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000746/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
747/// the prospective base classes.
748static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
749 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
750 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000751 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000752 return false;
753
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000754 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000755 if (!RD) return false;
756 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
757
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
759 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
760 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
761 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
762 if (!BaseRT) return false;
763
764 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
766 return false;
767 }
768
769 return true;
770}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000771
John McCall144238e2009-12-02 20:26:00 +0000772/// Determines if this is an instance member of a class.
773static bool IsInstanceMember(NamedDecl *D) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000774 assert(D->isCXXClassMember() &&
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000775 "checking whether non-member is instance member");
776
777 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000778
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000779 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(D))
780 return !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)->isStatic();
781
782 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) {
783 D = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl();
784 return !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)->isStatic();
785 }
786
787 return false;
788}
789
790enum IMAKind {
791 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
792 IMA_Static,
793
794 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
795 IMA_Mixed,
796
797 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
798 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
799 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
800
801 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
802 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
803 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
804
805 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
806 IMA_Instance,
807
808 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
809 IMA_Unresolved,
810
811 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
812 /// context is not an instance method.
813 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
814
815 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
816 /// non-class context.
817 IMA_AnonymousMember,
818
819 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
820 /// context is not an instance method.
821 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
822
823 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
824 /// class.
825 IMA_Error_Unrelated
826};
827
828/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
829/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
830/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
831/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
832/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
833/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
834static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
835 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000836 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000837
838 bool isStaticContext =
839 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext) ||
840 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->isStatic());
841
842 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
843 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
844
845 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
846 bool hasNonInstance = false;
847 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
848 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
849 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
850 if (IsInstanceMember(D)) {
851 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
852
853 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
854 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
855 // that's a special case.
856 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
857 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
858 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
859 }
860 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
861 }
862 else
863 hasNonInstance = true;
864 }
865
866 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
867 // member reference.
868 if (Classes.empty())
869 return IMA_Static;
870
871 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
872 // an implicit member reference.
873 if (isStaticContext)
874 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
875
876 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
877 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
878 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
879 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
880 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->getParent(),
881 Classes))
882 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
883
884 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
885}
886
887/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
888static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
889 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
890 const LookupResult &R) {
891 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
892 SourceRange Range(Loc);
893 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
894
895 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
896 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
897 if (MD->isStatic()) {
898 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
899 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
900 << Range << R.getLookupName();
901 return;
902 }
903 }
904
905 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
906 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
907 return;
908 }
909
910 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000911}
912
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000913/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
914///
915/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000916bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000917 LookupResult &R) {
918 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
919
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000920 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000921 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
923 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000924 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000926 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
927 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000928
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000929 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
930 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
931 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
932 // dependent name.
933 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
934 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000935 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
936 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
937
938 if (!R.empty()) {
939 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
940 R.suppressDiagnostics();
941
942 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
943 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
944 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
945 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
946
947 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
948 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
949 // Actually quite difficult!
950 if (isInstance)
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
952 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(),
953 "this->");
954 else
955 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
956
957 // Do we really want to note all of these?
958 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
959 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
960
961 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
962 return false;
963 }
964 }
965 }
966
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000967 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000968 if (S && CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS)) {
969 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
970 if (SS.isEmpty())
971 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
972 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000973 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000974 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000975 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
976 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
977 << SS.getRange()
978 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000979 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +0000980 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
981 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
982 << ND->getDeclName();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000983
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000984 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
985 return false;
986 }
987
988 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
989 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
990 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
991 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
992 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
993 // to recover well anyway.
994 if (SS.isEmpty())
995 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000996 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
998 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
999 << SS.getRange();
1000
1001 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1002 return true;
1003 }
1004
1005 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001006 }
1007
1008 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1009 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1010 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1011 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1012 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1013 << SS.getRange();
1014 return true;
1015 }
1016
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001017 // Give up, we can't recover.
1018 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1019 return true;
1020}
1021
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001022Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
1023 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1024 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1025 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1026 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1027 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1028 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1029
1030 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001031 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001032
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001033 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001034
1035 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1036 DeclarationName Name;
1037 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1038 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001039 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1040 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001041
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001042 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001043
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001044 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1045 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001046 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1047 // (note: handled after lookup)
1048 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1049 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1050 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001051 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1052 // names a dependent type.
1053 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1054 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001055 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1056 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1057 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001058 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001059 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001060 TemplateArgs);
1061 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001062
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001063 // Perform the required lookup.
1064 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1065 if (TemplateArgs) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 // Just re-use the lookup done by isTemplateName.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001067 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001068 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001069 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1070 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001071
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1073 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001074 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1075 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076 if (E.isInvalid())
1077 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001078
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1080 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001081 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001082 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001083
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1085 return ExprError();
1086
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001087 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1088 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001090
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001091 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001092 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1094 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1095 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1096 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1097 }
1098
1099 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1100 // call, diagnose the problem.
1101 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001102 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001103 return ExprError();
1104
1105 assert(!R.empty() &&
1106 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001107
1108 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1109 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001110 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001111 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1112 R.clear();
1113 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1114 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1115 return move(E);
1116 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001117 }
1118 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001119
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001120 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1121 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1122
1123 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 // Warn about constructs like:
1125 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1126 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001127
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001128 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1129 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001130 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001131 if (CheckS->isWithinElse() &&
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001132 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001134 << Var->getDeclName()
1135 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType()? 2 :
1136 Var->getType()->isBooleanType()? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001137 break;
1138 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001139
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001140 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1141 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001142 }
1143 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001145 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1146 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1147 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1148 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1149 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1150 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001152 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001153
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001154 QualType T = Func->getType();
1155 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001156 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001157 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001158 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001159 }
1160 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001161
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001162 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1163 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1164 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1165 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1166 // class member access expression.
1167 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1168 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001169 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001171 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1172 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001173 }
1174
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 if (TemplateArgs)
1176 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001177
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001178 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1179}
1180
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001181/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1182Sema::OwningExprResult
1183Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1184 LookupResult &R,
1185 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1186 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1187 case IMA_Instance:
1188 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1189
1190 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1191 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1192 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1193 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1194
1195 case IMA_Mixed:
1196 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1197 case IMA_Unresolved:
1198 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1199
1200 case IMA_Static:
1201 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1202 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1203 if (TemplateArgs)
1204 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1205 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1206
1207 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1208 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1209 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1210 return ExprError();
1211 }
1212
1213 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1214 return ExprError();
1215}
1216
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001217/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1218/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1219/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1220/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001221Sema::OwningExprResult
1222Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1223 DeclarationName Name,
1224 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1225 DeclContext *DC;
1226 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) ||
1227 DC->isDependentContext() ||
1228 RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS))
1229 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1230
1231 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1232 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1233
1234 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1235 return ExprError();
1236
1237 if (R.empty()) {
1238 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1239 return ExprError();
1240 }
1241
1242 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1243}
1244
1245/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1246/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1247/// additional lookup.
1248///
1249/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1250/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1251///
1252/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1253Sema::OwningExprResult
1254Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001255 IdentifierInfo *II,
1256 bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001257 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
1258
1259 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1260 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1261 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1262 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1263 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1264
1265 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1266 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1267 // ivar, that's an error.
1268 bool IsClassMethod = getCurMethodDecl()->isClassMethod();
1269
1270 bool LookForIvars;
1271 if (Lookup.empty())
1272 LookForIvars = true;
1273 else if (IsClassMethod)
1274 LookForIvars = false;
1275 else
1276 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1277 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001278 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001279 if (LookForIvars) {
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001280 IFace = getCurMethodDecl()->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001281 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1282 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1283 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1284 if (IsClassMethod)
1285 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1286 << IV->getDeclName());
1287
1288 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1289 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1290 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1291 return ExprError();
1292
1293 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1294 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1295 return ExprError();
1296
1297 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1298 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1299 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1300 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1301
1302 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1303 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1304 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1305 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001306 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001307 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1308 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1309 SelfName, false, false);
1310 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1311 return Owned(new (Context)
1312 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1313 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1314 }
1315 } else if (getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod()) {
1316 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
1317 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = getCurMethodDecl()->getClassInterface();
1318 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1319 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1320 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1321 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1322 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1323 }
1324 }
1325
1326 // Needed to implement property "super.method" notation.
1327 if (Lookup.empty() && II->isStr("super")) {
1328 QualType T;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001329
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001330 if (getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod())
1331 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(Context.getObjCInterfaceType(
1332 getCurMethodDecl()->getClassInterface()));
1333 else
1334 T = Context.getObjCClassType();
1335 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCSuperExpr(Loc, T));
1336 }
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001337 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1338 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1339 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1340 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1341 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1342 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1343 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1344 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1345 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1346 }
1347 }
1348 }
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001349 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI2 && LookForIvars && Lookup.empty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian77e2dde2010-02-09 21:49:50 +00001350 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = SynthesizeNewPropertyIvar(IFace, II);
1351 if (Ivar)
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001352 return LookupInObjCMethod(Lookup, S, II, AllowBuiltinCreation);
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001353 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001354 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1355 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001356}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001357
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001358/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1359///
1360/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1361///
1362/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1363/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1364/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1365/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1366///
1367/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1368/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1369/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1370/// the class declaring the member.
1371///
1372/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1373/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1374/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001375bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001376Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1377 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001378 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001379 NamedDecl *Member) {
1380 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1381 if (!RD)
1382 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001383
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001384 QualType DestRecordType;
1385 QualType DestType;
1386 QualType FromRecordType;
1387 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1388 bool PointerConversions = false;
1389 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1390 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001391
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001392 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1393 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1394 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1395 PointerConversions = true;
1396 } else {
1397 DestType = DestRecordType;
1398 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001399 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1401 if (Method->isStatic())
1402 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001403
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001404 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1405 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001406
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001407 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1408 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1409 PointerConversions = true;
1410 } else {
1411 FromRecordType = FromType;
1412 DestType = DestRecordType;
1413 }
1414 } else {
1415 // No conversion necessary.
1416 return false;
1417 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001418
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001419 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1420 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001421
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001422 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1423 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1424 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001425
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001426 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1427 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1428
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001429 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001430 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001431 // class name.
1432 //
1433 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1434 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1435 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1436 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1437 //
1438 // class Base { public: int x; };
1439 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1440 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1441 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1442 //
1443 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1444 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1445 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1446 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001447 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001448 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1449 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1450 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1451
1452 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1453
1454 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1455 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1456 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1457 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
1458 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
1459 FromLoc, FromRange))
1460 return true;
1461
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001462 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001463 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001464 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001465 /*isLvalue*/ !PointerConversions);
1466
1467 FromType = QType;
1468 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1469
1470 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1471 // we're done.
1472 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1473 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001474 }
1475 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001476
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001477 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001478
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001479 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1480 // down to the using declaration's type.
1481 //
1482 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1483 // class ever has member declarations.
1484 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1485 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1486 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1487 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1488
1489 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1490 // conversion is non-trivial.
1491 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1492 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
1493 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
1494 FromLoc, FromRange))
1495 return true;
1496
1497 QualType UType = URecordType;
1498 if (PointerConversions)
1499 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001500 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001501 /*isLvalue*/ !PointerConversions);
1502 FromType = UType;
1503 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1504 }
1505
1506 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1507 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1508 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001509 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001511 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType,
1512 DestRecordType,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001513 FromLoc,
1514 FromRange,
1515 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001517
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001518 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1519 /*isLvalue=*/ !PointerConversions);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001520 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001521}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001522
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001523/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001524static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001525 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001526 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, SourceLocation Loc,
1527 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001528 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1529 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1530 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001531 if (SS.isSet()) {
1532 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1533 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001534 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001535
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001536 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001537 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001538}
1539
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001540/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1541/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1542/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1543/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001544Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001545Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1546 LookupResult &R,
1547 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1548 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001549 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1550
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001551 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001552
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001553 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1554 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001555 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001556 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001557 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001558 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001559 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001560
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001561 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1562 // 'this' expression now.
1563 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)->getThisType(Context);
1564 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1565 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001566 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1567 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1568 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1569 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001570 }
1571
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001572 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1573 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1574 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001575 SS,
1576 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1577 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001578}
1579
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001580bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001581 const LookupResult &R,
1582 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001583 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1584 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1585 return false;
1586
1587 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001588 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001589 return false;
1590
1591 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001592 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001593 return false;
1594
1595 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1596 // normal lookup:
1597 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1598 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1599
1600 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1601 // -- a declaration of a class member
1602 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1603 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001604 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001605 return false;
1606
1607 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1608 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1609 // using-declaration
1610 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1611 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1612 // turn off ADL anyway).
1613 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1614 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1615 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1616 return false;
1617
1618 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1619 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1620 // template
1621 // And also for builtin functions.
1622 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1623 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1624
1625 // But also builtin functions.
1626 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1627 return false;
1628 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1629 return false;
1630 }
1631
1632 return true;
1633}
1634
1635
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001636/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1637/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1638/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1639/// will in fact be used.
1640static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1641 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1642 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1643 return true;
1644 }
1645
1646 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1647 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1648 return true;
1649 }
1650
1651 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1652 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1653 return true;
1654 }
1655
1656 return false;
1657}
1658
1659Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001660Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001661 LookupResult &R,
1662 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001663 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1664 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001665 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001666 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001667
1668 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1669 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1670 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001671 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1672 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001673 return ExprError();
1674
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001675 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1676 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1677 // we've picked a target.
1678 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1679
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001680 bool Dependent
1681 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001682 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001683 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001684 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1685 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001686 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1687 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001688 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001689
1690 return Owned(ULE);
1691}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001692
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001693
1694/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1695Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001696Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001697 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1698 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001699 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1700 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001701
1702 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1703 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001704
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001705 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1706 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1707 // a template argument list.
1708 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1709 << Template << SS.getRange();
1710 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1711 return ExprError();
1712 }
1713
1714 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1715 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1716 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001717 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001718 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001719 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001720 return ExprError();
1721 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001722
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001723 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1724 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1725 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1726 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001727 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001728 return ExprError();
1729
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001730 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1731 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001732 return ExprError();
1733
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001734 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1735 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1736 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1737 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001738 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001739 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1740 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1741 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001742 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001743 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001744 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1745 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1746 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1747 return ExprError();
1748 }
1749
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001750 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001751 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1752 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1753 return ExprError();
1754 }
1755
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001756 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001757 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001758 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001759 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001760 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001761 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1762 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001763 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001764
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001765 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001766 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001767 constAdded));
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001768 }
1769 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1770 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001771
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001772 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001773}
1774
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001775Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1776 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001777 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001778
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001779 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001780 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001781 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1782 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1783 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001784 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001785
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001786 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1787 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001788
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001789 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1790 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001791 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001792 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001793 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001794
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001795 QualType ResTy;
1796 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1797 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1798 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001799 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001800
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001801 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001802 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001803 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1804 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001805 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001806}
1807
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001808Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001809 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001810 bool Invalid = false;
1811 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1812 if (Invalid)
1813 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001814
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001815 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1816 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001817 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001819
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001820 QualType Ty;
1821 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1822 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1823 else if (Literal.isWide())
1824 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001825 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1826 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001827 else
1828 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001829
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001830 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1831 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001832 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001833}
1834
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001835Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1836 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001837 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1838 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001839 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001840 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001841 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001842 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001843 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001844
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001845 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001846 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1847 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001848 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001849
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001850 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001851 bool Invalid = false;
1852 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1853 if (Invalid)
1854 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001855
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001856 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001857 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1858 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001859 return ExprError();
1860
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001861 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001862
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001863 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001864 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001865 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001866 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001867 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001868 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001869 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001870 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001871
1872 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1873
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001874 using llvm::APFloat;
1875 APFloat Val(Format);
1876
1877 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001878
1879 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1880 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1881 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1882 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001883 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001884 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001885 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001886 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001887 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1888 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001889 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001890 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1891 }
1892
1893 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1894 << Ty
1895 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1896 }
1897
1898 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001899 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001900
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001901 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001902 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001903 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001904 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001905
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001906 // long long is a C99 feature.
1907 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001908 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001909 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1910
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001911 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001912 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001913
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001914 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1915 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1916 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001917 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1918 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001919 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001920 } else {
1921 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1922 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001923
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001924 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1925 // be an unsigned int.
1926 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1927
1928 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001929 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001930 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1931 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001932 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001933
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001934 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1935 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1936 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1937 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001938 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001939 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001940 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001941 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001942 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001943 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001944
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001945 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001946 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001947 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001948
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001949 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1950 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1951 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1952 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001953 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001954 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001955 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001956 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001957 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001958 }
1959
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001960 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001961 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001962 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001963
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001964 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1965 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1966 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1967 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001968 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001969 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001970 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001971 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001972 }
1973 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001974
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001975 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1976 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001977 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001978 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001979 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001980 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001981 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001982
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001983 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1984 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001985 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001986 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001987 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001988
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001989 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1990 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001991 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001992 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001993
1994 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001995}
1996
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001997Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1998 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001999 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002000 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002001 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002002}
2003
2004/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2005/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002006bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002007 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2008 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2009 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002010 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2011 return false;
2012
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002013 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2014 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2015 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2016 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2017 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2018 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2019
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002020 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002021 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002022 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002023 if (isSizeof)
2024 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2025 return false;
2026 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002027
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002028 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002029 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002030 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2031 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002032 return false;
2033 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002034
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002035 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002036 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2037 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002038 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002039
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002040 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
Fariborz Jahanianced1e282009-04-24 17:34:33 +00002041 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002042 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002043 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2044 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002045 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002046
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002047 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002048}
2049
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002050bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2051 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2052 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002053
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002054 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002055 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2056 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002057
2058 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2059 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2060 return false;
2061
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002062 if (E->getBitField()) {
2063 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2064 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002065 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002066
2067 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2068 // bit-field.
2069 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002070 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002071 return false;
2072
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002073 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2074}
2075
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002076/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002077Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002078Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002079 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002080 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002081 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002082 return ExprError();
2083
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002084 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002085
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002086 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2087 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2088 return ExprError();
2089
2090 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002091 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002092 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2093 R.getEnd()));
2094}
2095
2096/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2097/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002098Action::OwningExprResult
2099Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002100 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2101 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2102 bool isInvalid = false;
2103 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2104 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2105 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2106 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002107 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002108 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2109 isInvalid = true;
2110 } else {
2111 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2112 }
2113
2114 if (isInvalid)
2115 return ExprError();
2116
2117 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2118 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2119 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2120 R.getEnd()));
2121}
2122
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002123/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2124/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2125/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002126Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002127Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2128 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002129 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002130 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002131
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002132 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002133 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2134 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2135 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002136 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002137
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002138 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2139 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2140 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2141
2142 if (Result.isInvalid())
2143 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2144
2145 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002146}
2147
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002148QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002149 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2150 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002151
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002152 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002153 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002154 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002156 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2157 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2158 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002159
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002160 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002161 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2162 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002163 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002164}
2165
2166
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002167
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002168Action::OwningExprResult
2169Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2170 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002171 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2172 switch (Kind) {
2173 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2174 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2175 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2176 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002177
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002178 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002179}
2180
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002181Action::OwningExprResult
2182Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2183 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002184 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2185 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2186
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002187 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2188 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002189
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002190 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002191 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2192 Base.release();
2193 Idx.release();
2194 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2195 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2196 }
2197
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002198 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002199 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002200 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2201 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2202 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002203 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002204 }
2205
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002206 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2207}
2208
2209
2210Action::OwningExprResult
2211Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2212 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2213 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2214 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2215
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002216 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002217 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2218 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2219 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002220
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002221 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002222
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002223 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002224 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002225 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002226 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002227 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2228 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002229 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2230 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2231 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2232 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002233 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002234 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2235 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002236 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002237 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002238 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002239 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2240 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002241 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002242 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002243 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002244 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2245 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2246 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002247 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002248 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002249 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2250 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2251 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2252 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002253 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002254 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002255 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002256
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002257 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2258 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002259 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2260 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002261 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002262 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2263 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2264 // force the promotion here.
2265 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2266 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002267 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2268 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2270
2271 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2272 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002273 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002274 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2275 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2276 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2277 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002278 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2279 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002280 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2281
2282 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2283 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002284 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002285 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002286 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2287 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002288 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002289 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002290 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2291 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002292 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2293 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002294
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002295 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002296 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2297 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002298 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2299
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002300 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002301 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2302 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002303 // incomplete types are not object types.
2304 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2305 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2306 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2307 return ExprError();
2308 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002309
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002310 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002312 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2313 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002314 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002315
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002316 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
2317 if (ResultType->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
2318 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2319 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2320 return ExprError();
2321 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002322
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002323 Base.release();
2324 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002325 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002326 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002327}
2328
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002329QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002330CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002331 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002332 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002333 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2334 // see FIXME there.
2335 //
2336 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2337 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002338 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002339
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002340 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002341 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002342
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002343 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002344 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2345 // to be selected.
2346 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002347
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002348 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2349 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002350 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002351
2352 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2353 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002354 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2356 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002357 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002358 do
2359 compStr++;
2360 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002361 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002362 do
2363 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002365 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002366
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002367 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002368 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2369 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002370 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2371 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002372 return QualType();
2373 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002374
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002375 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2376 // operates on.
2377 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002378 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002379
2380 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002381 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002382
2383 while (*compStr) {
2384 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2385 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2386 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2387 return QualType();
2388 }
2389 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002390 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002391
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002392 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002393 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002394 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002395 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002396 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002397 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002398 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002399 if (HexSwizzle)
2400 CompSize--;
2401
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002402 if (CompSize == 1)
2403 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002404
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002405 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002406 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002407 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2408 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2409 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2410 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002411 }
2412 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002413}
2414
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002415static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002416 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002417 const Selector &Sel,
2418 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002419
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002420 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002421 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002422 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002423 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002424
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002425 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2426 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002427 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002428 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002429 return D;
2430 }
2431 return 0;
2432}
2433
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002434static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002435 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002436 const Selector &Sel,
2437 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002438 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2439 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002440 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002441 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002442 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002443 GDecl = PD;
2444 break;
2445 }
2446 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002447 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002448 GDecl = OMD;
2449 break;
2450 }
2451 }
2452 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002453 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002454 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2455 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002456 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002457 if (GDecl)
2458 return GDecl;
2459 }
2460 }
2461 return GDecl;
2462}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002463
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002465Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2466 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002467 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2468 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2469 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2470 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2471 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2472
2473 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2474 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2475 //
2476 // T* t;
2477 // t.f;
2478 //
2479 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2480 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2481 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2482 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002483 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002484 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2485 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002486 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002487 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002488 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002489 return ExprError();
2490 }
2491 }
2492
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00002493 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002494
2495 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2496 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002497 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002498 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2499 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2500 SS.getRange(),
2501 FirstQualifierInScope,
2502 Name, NameLoc,
2503 TemplateArgs));
2504}
2505
2506/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2507/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2508/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2509static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2510 Expr *BaseExpr,
2511 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002512 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002513 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002514 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2515 // diagnostics.
2516 if (!BaseExpr)
2517 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002518
2519 // FIXME: this is an exceedingly lame diagnostic for some of the more
2520 // complicated cases here.
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002521 DeclContext *DC = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getDeclContext();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002522 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_direct_base_or_virtual)
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002523 << SS.getRange() << DC << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002524}
2525
2526// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2527// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2528// type. The restriction here is:
2529//
2530// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2531// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2532// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2533//
2534// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2535// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2536// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2537// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2538bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2539 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002540 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002541 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002542 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2543 if (!BaseRT) {
2544 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2545 // dependent.
2546 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2547 return false;
2548 }
2549 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002550
2551 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002552 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2553 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
2554 if (!BaseExpr && !IsInstanceMember((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
2555 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002556
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2558 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2559 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2560 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2561
2562 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2563 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2564
2565 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2566 return false;
2567 }
2568
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002569 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002570 return true;
2571}
2572
2573static bool
2574LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2575 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
2576 SourceLocation OpLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
2577 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2578 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002579 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002580 << BaseRange))
2581 return true;
2582
2583 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2584 if (SS.isSet()) {
2585 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2586 // nested-name-specifier.
2587 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2588
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002589 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS)) {
2590 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2591 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2592 return true;
2593 }
2594
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002595 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002596
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002597 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2598 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2599 << DC << SS.getRange();
2600 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002601 }
2602 }
2603
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002604 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2605 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002606
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002607 if (!R.empty())
2608 return false;
2609
2610 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2611 // for typos.
2612 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002613 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC) &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002614 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2615 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2616 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
2617 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2618 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002619 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2620 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2621 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002622 return false;
2623 } else {
2624 R.clear();
2625 }
2626
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002627 return false;
2628}
2629
2630Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002632 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2633 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2634 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2635 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2636 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2637 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2638
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002639 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2640 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002641 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002642 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2643 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2644 Name, NameLoc,
2645 TemplateArgs);
2646
2647 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002649 // Implicit member accesses.
2650 if (!Base) {
2651 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2652 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2653 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2654 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2655 OpLoc, SS))
2656 return ExprError();
2657
2658 // Explicit member accesses.
2659 } else {
2660 OwningExprResult Result =
2661 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002662 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002663
2664 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2665 Owned(Base);
2666 return ExprError();
2667 }
2668
2669 if (Result.get())
2670 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671 }
2672
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002673 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002674 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2675 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002676}
2677
2678Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2680 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2681 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002682 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002683 LookupResult &R,
2684 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2685 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002686 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 if (IsArrow) {
2688 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2689 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2690 }
2691
2692 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2693 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2694 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2695 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2696
2697 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002698 return ExprError();
2699
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002700 if (R.empty()) {
2701 // Rederive where we looked up.
2702 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2703 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2704 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002705
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707 << MemberName << DC
2708 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002709 return ExprError();
2710 }
2711
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002712 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2713 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2714 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2715 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2716 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2717 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2718 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2719 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2720 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2721 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
2722 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002723 return ExprError();
2724
2725 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2726 // result.
2727 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002728 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002729 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002730 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002731 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002732
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002733 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2734 // pick a member.
2735 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2736
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002737 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2738 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2739 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002740 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2741 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002742 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2743 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2744 TemplateArgs);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002745 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002746
2747 return Owned(MemExpr);
2748 }
2749
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002750 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002751 NamedDecl *FoundDecl = *R.begin();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002752 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2753
2754 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2755
2756 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2757 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2758 // error cases.
2759 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2760 return ExprError();
2761
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002762 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2763 if (!BaseExpr) {
2764 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
2765 if (!IsInstanceMember(MemberDecl))
2766 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2767
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002768 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2769 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2770 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2771 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002772 }
2773
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002774 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2775 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2776 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2777 // explicitly qualified.
2778 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2779 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2780 }
2781
2782 // Check the use of this member.
2783 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2784 Owned(BaseExpr);
2785 return ExprError();
2786 }
2787
2788 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2789 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2790 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002791 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2792 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002793 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2794 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2795
2796 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2797 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2798 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2799 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2800 else {
2801 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2802 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2803 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2804
2805 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2806 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2807
2808 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2809 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2810 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2811 }
2812
2813 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002814 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002815 return ExprError();
2816 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002817 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 }
2819
2820 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2821 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2822 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002823 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002824 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2825 }
2826
2827 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2828 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2829 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002830 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831 MemberFn->getType()));
2832 }
2833
2834 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2835 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2836 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002837 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002838 }
2839
2840 Owned(BaseExpr);
2841
2842 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
2843 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2844 << MemberName << int(IsArrow));
2845
2846 // We found a declaration kind that we didn't expect. This is a
2847 // generic error message that tells the user that she can't refer
2848 // to this member with '.' or '->'.
2849 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc,
2850 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2851 << MemberName << int(IsArrow));
2852}
2853
2854/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2855/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2856/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2857/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2858/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2859/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2860/// an ordinary member expression.
2861///
2862/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2863/// fixed for ObjC++.
2864Sema::OwningExprResult
2865Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002866 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002868 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002869 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002870
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002871 // Perform default conversions.
2872 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002873
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002874 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002875 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2876
2877 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2878 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002879
2880 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002881 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002882 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2883 // call, and continue on.
2884 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2885 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2886 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2887 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2888 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002889 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2890 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002891 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2892 ->isRecordType()))) {
2893 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2894 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2895 << QualType(Fun, 0)
2896 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002897
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002898 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002899 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002900 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2901 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002902 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002903
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002904 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2905 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2906 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2907 }
2908 }
2909 }
2910
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002911 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2912 // use that.
2913 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002914 if (IsArrow) {
2915 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2916 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2917 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2918 if (OPT->getPointeeType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
2919 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002920 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2921 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002922 }
2923 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002924 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2925 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2926 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2927 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002928 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002929 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002930 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002931
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002932 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2933 // use that.
2934 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2935 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2936 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2937 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2938 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2939 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2940 }
2941 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002942
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002943 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002944
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002945 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002946 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002947 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2948 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2949 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2950 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2951 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2952 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2953 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2954 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2955 // Check the use of this method.
2956 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2957 return ExprError();
2958 }
2959 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2960 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2961 Selector SetterSel =
2962 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2963 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2964 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2965 if (!Setter) {
2966 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2967 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002968 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002969 }
2970 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2971 if (!Setter)
2972 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002973
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002974 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2975 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002976
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002977 if (Getter || Setter) {
2978 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002979
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002980 if (Getter)
2981 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2982 else
2983 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2984 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2985 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002986 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002987 PType,
2988 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2989 }
2990 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2991 << MemberName << BaseType);
2992 }
2993 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002994
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002995 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
2996 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
2997 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002998 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002999 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003000
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003001 if (IsArrow) {
3002 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003003 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003004 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3005 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003006 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3007 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3008 // struct MyRecord foo;
3009 // foo->bar
3010 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3011 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3012 // by now.
3013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3014 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
3015 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
3016 IsArrow = false;
3017 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003018 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3019 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3020 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003021 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003022 } else {
3023 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3024 // type *foo;
3025 // foo.bar
3026 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3027 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3028 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3029 // the appropriate pointer type
3030 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3031 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3032 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3033 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3034 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
3035 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
3036 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3037 IsArrow = true;
3038 }
3039 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003040 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003041
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003042 // Handle field access to simple records. This also handles access
3043 // to fields of the ObjC 'id' struct.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003044 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003045 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3046 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003047 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003048 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003049 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003050
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003051 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3052 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003053 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
3054 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCInterfaceType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003055 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003056 const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003057 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceType() : BaseType->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003058 if (IFaceT) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003059 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3060
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003061 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = IFaceT->getDecl();
3062 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003063 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003064
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003065 if (!IV) {
3066 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3067 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3068 LookupMemberName);
3069 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl) &&
3070 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003071 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003072 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3073 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
3074 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3075 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003076 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003077 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003078 }
3079 }
3080
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003081 if (IV) {
3082 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3083 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3084 // error cases.
3085 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3086 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003087
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003088 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3089 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3090 return ExprError();
3091 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3092 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3093 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3094 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3095 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3096 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3097 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3098 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3099 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3100 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3101 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3102 // AST for a function decl.
3103 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003104 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003105 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3106 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3107 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3108 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3109 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3110 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003111
3112 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3113 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003114 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003115 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003116 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003117 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3118 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003119 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003120 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003121 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003122
3123 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3124 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003125 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003126 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003127 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003128 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003129 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003130 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003131 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003132 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3134 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003135 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003136 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003137
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003138 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003139 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003140 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3141 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3142 // Check the use of this declaration
3143 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3144 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003145
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003146 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3147 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3148 }
3149 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3150 // Check the use of this method.
3151 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3152 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003153
Ted Kremenekeb3b3242010-02-11 22:41:21 +00003154 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCMessageExpr(Context, BaseExpr, Sel,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003155 OMD->getResultType(),
3156 OMD, OpLoc, MemberLoc,
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003157 NULL, 0));
3158 }
3159 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003160
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003161 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003162 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003163 }
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003164 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3165 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003166 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003167 if (!IsArrow && (OPT = BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003168 const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = OPT->getInterfaceType();
3169 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003170 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003171
Daniel Dunbar2307d312008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003172 // Search for a declared property first.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003173 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = IFace->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003174 // Check whether we can reference this property.
3175 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3176 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian4c2743f2009-05-08 19:36:34 +00003177 QualType ResTy = PD->getType();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003178 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003179 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter = IFace->lookupInstanceMethod(Sel);
Fariborz Jahanianc001e892009-05-08 20:20:55 +00003180 if (DiagnosePropertyAccessorMismatch(PD, Getter, MemberLoc))
3181 ResTy = Getter->getResultType();
Fariborz Jahanian4c2743f2009-05-08 19:36:34 +00003182 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, ResTy,
Chris Lattner7eba82e2009-02-16 18:35:08 +00003183 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3184 }
Daniel Dunbar2307d312008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003185 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00003186 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
3187 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003188 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003189 // Check whether we can reference this property.
3190 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3191 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner7eba82e2009-02-16 18:35:08 +00003192
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003193 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Chris Lattner7eba82e2009-02-16 18:35:08 +00003194 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3195 }
Daniel Dunbar2307d312008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003196 // If that failed, look for an "implicit" property by seeing if the nullary
3197 // selector is implemented.
3198
3199 // FIXME: The logic for looking up nullary and unary selectors should be
3200 // shared with the code in ActOnInstanceMessage.
3201
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003202 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003203 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter = IFace->lookupInstanceMethod(Sel);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003204
Daniel Dunbar2307d312008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003205 // If this reference is in an @implementation, check for 'private' methods.
3206 if (!Getter)
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003207 Getter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(Sel);
Daniel Dunbar2307d312008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003208
Steve Naroff7692ed62008-10-22 19:16:27 +00003209 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1cb35dd2009-07-21 00:06:20 +00003210 if (!Getter)
3211 Getter = IFace->getCategoryInstanceMethod(Sel);
Daniel Dunbar2307d312008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003212 if (Getter) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003213 // Check if we can reference this property.
3214 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3215 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff1ca66942009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003216 }
3217 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3218 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003219 Selector SetterSel =
3220 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003221 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003222 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Steve Naroff1ca66942009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003223 if (!Setter) {
3224 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3225 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003226 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Steve Naroff1ca66942009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003227 }
3228 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1cb35dd2009-07-21 00:06:20 +00003229 if (!Setter)
3230 Setter = IFace->getCategoryInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003231
Steve Naroff1ca66942009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003232 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3233 return ExprError();
3234
Fariborz Jahaniandd0cb902010-01-19 17:48:02 +00003235 if (Getter) {
Steve Naroff1ca66942009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003236 QualType PType;
Fariborz Jahaniandd0cb902010-01-19 17:48:02 +00003237 PType = Getter->getResultType();
Fariborz Jahanian09105f52009-08-20 17:02:02 +00003238 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter, PType,
Steve Naroff1ca66942009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003239 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3240 }
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003241
3242 // Attempt to correct for typos in property names.
3243 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3244 LookupOrdinaryName);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003245 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IFace, false, OPT) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003246 Res.getAsSingle<ObjCPropertyDecl>()) {
3247 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_property_not_found_suggest)
3248 << MemberName << BaseType << Res.getLookupName()
3249 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3250 Res.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003251 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCPropertyDecl>();
3252 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003253 << Property->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003254
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003255 return LookupMemberExpr(Res, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003256 ObjCImpDecl);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003257 }
Fariborz Jahanian354095c2010-02-19 18:30:30 +00003258 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3259 << MemberName << BaseType;
3260 if (Setter && !Getter)
3261 Diag(Setter->getLocation(), diag::note_getter_unavailable)
3262 << MemberName << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3263 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian232220c2007-11-12 22:29:28 +00003264 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003265
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003266 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003267 if (!IsArrow &&
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003268 BaseType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003269 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003270 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003271 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003272
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003273 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003274 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003275 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003276 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3277 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003278 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003279 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003280 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003281 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003282
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003283 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3284 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3285
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003286 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003287}
3288
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003289/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3290/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3291/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3292/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3293/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3294///
3295/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3296/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3297/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3298/// only be called
3299/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3300/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3301/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3302Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3303 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3304 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
3305 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3306 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3307 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3308 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3309 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3310 return ExprError();
3311
3312 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3313
3314 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3315 DeclarationName Name;
3316 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3317 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3318 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3319 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3320
3321 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3322
3323 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3324 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3325 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3326
3327 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3328 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3329
3330 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3331 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00003332 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003333 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003334 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3335 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3336 Name, NameLoc,
3337 TemplateArgs);
3338 } else {
3339 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3340 if (TemplateArgs) {
3341 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3342 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
3343 } else {
3344 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003345 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003346
3347 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3348 Owned(Base);
3349 return ExprError();
3350 }
3351
3352 if (Result.get()) {
3353 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3354 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3355 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3356 // call now.
3357 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3358 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor77549082010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003359 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003360
3361 return move(Result);
3362 }
3363 }
3364
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003365 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003366 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3367 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003368 }
3369
3370 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003371}
3372
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003373Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3374 FunctionDecl *FD,
3375 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3376 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3377 Diag (CallLoc,
3378 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3379 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003380 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003381 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3382 } else {
3383 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3384 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3385
3386 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003387 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3388 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003389
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003390 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3391 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregord6350ae2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003392 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003393
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003394 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003395 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003396 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003397
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003398 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3399 InitializedEntity Entity
3400 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3401 InitializationKind Kind
3402 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3403 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3404 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3405
3406 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003407 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003408 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3409 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003410 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003411
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003412 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003413 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003414 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003415 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003416
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003417 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3418 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3419 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003420 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3421 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003422 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3423 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003424 }
3425
3426 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003427 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003428}
3429
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003430/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3431/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3432/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3433/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3434/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3435/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003436bool
3437Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003438 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003439 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003440 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3441 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003442 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003443 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3444 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003445 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003446
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003447 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3448 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3449 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3450 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3451 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
3452 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003453 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003454 }
3455
3456 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3457 // them.
3458 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3459 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3460 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3461 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
3462 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() << Fn->getSourceRange()
3463 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3464 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3465 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003466 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003467 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003468 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003469 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003470 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003471 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003472 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3473 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3474 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3475 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3476 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003477 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003478 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003479 if (Invalid)
3480 return true;
3481 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3482 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3483 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003484
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003485 return false;
3486}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003487
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003488bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3489 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3490 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3491 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3492 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3493 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003494 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003495 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3496 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3497 bool Invalid = false;
3498 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3499 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3500 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3501 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003502 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003503 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003504 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003505
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003506 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003507 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3508 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003509
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003510 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3511 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003512 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003513 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003514 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003515
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003516 // Pass the argument
3517 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3518 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3519 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003520
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003521
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003522 InitializedEntity Entity =
3523 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3524 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3525 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3526 SourceLocation(),
3527 Owned(Arg));
3528 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3529 return true;
3530
3531 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003532 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003533 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003534
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003535 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003536 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003537 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3538 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003539
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003540 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003541 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003542 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003543 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003544
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003545 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003546 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003547 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003548 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i < NumArgs; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00003550 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003551 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003552 }
3553 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003554 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003555}
3556
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003557/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003558/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3559/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003560Action::OwningExprResult
3561Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3562 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003563 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003564 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003565
3566 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3567 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003568
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003569 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003570 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003571 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003572
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003573 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003574 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3575 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3576 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3577 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3578 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
3579 << CodeModificationHint::CreateRemoval(
3580 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3581 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003582
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003583 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3584 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003585
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003586 NumArgs = 0;
3587 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003588
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003589 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3590 RParenLoc));
3591 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003592
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003593 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003594 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003595 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3596 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003597 bool Dependent = false;
3598 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3599 Dependent = true;
3600 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3601 Dependent = true;
3602
3603 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003604 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003605 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3606
3607 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3608 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3609 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3610 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3611
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003612 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3613
3614 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3615 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3616 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3617 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3618 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3619 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3620 // method template.
3621 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
3622 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*MemE->decls_begin()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003623 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003624
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003625 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3626 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003627 }
3628
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003629 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003630 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003631 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003632 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003633 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3634 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003635 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003636
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003637 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003638 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003639 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3640 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003641 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003642 dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(BO->getType())) {
3643 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003644
3645 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3646 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003647 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3648 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003649
3650 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3651 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003652 TheCall.get(), 0))
3653 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003654
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003655 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003656 RParenLoc))
3657 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003658
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003659 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3660 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003661 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003662 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3663 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003664 }
3665 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003666 }
3667
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003668 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003669 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003670 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003671
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003672 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003673 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3674 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
3675 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3676 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003677 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003678
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003679 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3680 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3681 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3682
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003683 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3684}
3685
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003686/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3687/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003688/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3689/// block-pointer type.
3690///
3691/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3692Sema::OwningExprResult
3693Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3694 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3695 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3696 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3697 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3698
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003699 // Promote the function operand.
3700 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3701
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003702 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3703 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003704 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3705 Args, NumArgs,
3706 Context.BoolTy,
3707 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003708
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003709 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3710 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3711 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3712 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003713 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003714 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003715 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3716 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003717 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003718 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003719 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003720 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003721 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003722 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003723 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3724 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3725
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003726 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003727 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003728 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3729 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003730 return ExprError();
3731
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003732 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003733 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003734
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003735 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003736 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003737 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003738 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003739 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003740 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003741
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003742 if (FDecl) {
3743 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3744 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3745 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6fb0aee2009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003746 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003747 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003748 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003749 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3750 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3751 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3752 }
3753 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003754 }
3755
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003756 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003757 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3758 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3759 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003760 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3761 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003762 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3763 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003764 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003765 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003766 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003767 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003768
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003769 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3770 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003771 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3772 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003773
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003774 // Check for sentinels
3775 if (NDecl)
3776 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003777
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003778 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003779 if (FDecl) {
3780 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3781 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003782
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003783 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003784 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3785 } else if (NDecl) {
3786 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3787 return ExprError();
3788 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003789
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003790 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003791}
3792
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003793Action::OwningExprResult
3794Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3795 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003796 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003797 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003798 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003799
3800 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3801 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3802 if (!TInfo)
3803 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3804
3805 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3806}
3807
3808Action::OwningExprResult
3809Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3810 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3811 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003812 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003813
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003814 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003815 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003816 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3817 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003818 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3819 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003820 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003821 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003822 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003823 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003824
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003825 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003826 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003827 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003828 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003829 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003830 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3831 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3832 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3833 &literalType);
3834 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003835 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003836 InitExpr.release();
3837 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003838
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003839 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003840 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003841 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003842 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003843 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003844
3845 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003846
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003847 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003848 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003849}
3850
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003851Action::OwningExprResult
3852Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003853 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3854 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3855 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003856
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003857 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003858 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003859
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00003860 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(LBraceLoc, InitList, NumInit,
3861 RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003862 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003863 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003864}
3865
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003866static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3867 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003868 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003869 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3870
3871 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3872 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003873 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3874 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003875 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003876 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3877 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3878 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003879
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003880 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3881 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3882 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3883 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3884 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3885 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3886 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3887 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003888
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003889 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3890 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3891 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3892 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3893 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3894 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003895
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003896 // FIXME: Assert here.
3897 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3898 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3899}
3900
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003901/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003902bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003903 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003904 CXXMethodDecl *& ConversionDecl,
3905 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003906 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003907 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, FunctionalStyle,
3908 ConversionDecl);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003909
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003910 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003911
3912 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3913 // type needs to be scalar.
3914 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3915 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003916 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3917 return false;
3918 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003919
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003920 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003921 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003922 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3923 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003924 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003925 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3926 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003927 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003928 return false;
3929 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003930
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003931 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003932 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003933 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003934 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003935 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003936 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003937 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003938 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003939 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3940 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3941 break;
3942 }
3943 }
3944 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3945 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3946 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003947 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003948 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003949 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003950
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003951 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3952 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3953 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3954 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003955
3956 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003957 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003958 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3959 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003960 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003961 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003962
3963 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003964 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003965
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003966 if (castType->isVectorType())
3967 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3968 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3969 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3970
3971 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && isa<ObjCSuperExpr>(castExpr))
Steve Naroffa0c3e9c2009-04-08 23:52:26 +00003972 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_illegal_super_cast) << TyR;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003973
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003974 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3975 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003976
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003977 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003978 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3979 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3980 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3981 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3982 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3983 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3984 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3985 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3986 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3987 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003988 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003989
3990 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003991 return false;
3992}
3993
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003994bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3995 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003996 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003997
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003998 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003999 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004000 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004001 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004002 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004003 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004004 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004005 } else
4006 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004007 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004008 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004009
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004010 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004011 return false;
4012}
4013
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004014bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004015 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004016 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004017
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004018 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004019
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004020 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4021 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004022 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4023 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4024 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4025 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004026 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004027 return false;
4028 }
4029
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004030 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004031 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4032 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004033 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4034 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4035 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4036 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004037
4038 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4039 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4040 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004041
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004042 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004043 return false;
4044}
4045
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004046Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004047Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004048 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4049 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4050 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004051
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004052 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4053 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4054 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004055 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004056
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004057 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004058 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004059 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004060 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4061 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004062
4063 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4064}
4065
4066Action::OwningExprResult
4067Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4068 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4069 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4070
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004071 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004072 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
4073 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004074 Kind, Method))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004075 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004076
4077 if (Method) {
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004078 // FIXME: preserve type source info here
4079 OwningExprResult CastArg = BuildCXXCastArgument(LParenLoc, Ty->getType(),
4080 Kind, Method, move(Op));
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00004081
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004082 if (CastArg.isInvalid())
4083 return ExprError();
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00004084
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004085 castExpr = CastArg.takeAs<Expr>();
4086 } else {
4087 Op.release();
Fariborz Jahanian31976592009-08-29 19:15:16 +00004088 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004089
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004090 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
4091 Kind, castExpr, Ty,
Anders Carlssoncdb61972009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004092 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004093}
4094
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004095/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4096/// of comma binary operators.
4097Action::OwningExprResult
4098Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4099 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4100 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4101 if (!E)
4102 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004103
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004104 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004105
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004106 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4107 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4108 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004109
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004110 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4111}
4112
4113Action::OwningExprResult
4114Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4115 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004116 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004117 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004118 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004119
4120 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004121 // then handle it as such.
4122 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4123 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4124 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4125 return ExprError();
4126 }
4127
4128 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4129 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4130 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4131
4132 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4133 // braces instead of the original commas.
4134 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004135 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(LParenLoc, &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004136 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4137 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004138 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004139 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004140 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004141 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4142 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004143 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004144 }
4145}
4146
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004147Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004148 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004149 MultiExprArg Val,
4150 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004151 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4152 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004153 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4154 Expr *expr;
4155 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4156 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4157 else
4158 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004159 return Owned(expr);
4160}
4161
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004162/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4163/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004164/// C99 6.5.15
4165QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4166 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004167 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4168 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4169 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4170
John McCalld1b47bf2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00004171 CheckSignCompare(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
John McCallb13c87f2009-11-05 09:23:39 +00004172
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004173 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4174 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4175 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4176 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4177 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4178 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004179
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004180 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004181 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4182 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4183 << CondTy;
4184 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004185 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004186
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004187 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004188 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4189 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004190
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004191 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4192 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004193 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4194 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4195 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004196 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004197
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004198 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4199 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004200 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4201 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004202 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004203 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004204 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004205 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004206 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004207 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004208
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004209 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004210 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004211 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4212 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4213 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4214 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4215 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4216 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4217 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004218 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4219 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004220 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004221 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004222 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4223 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004224 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004225 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004226 // promote the null to a pointer.
4227 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004228 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004229 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004230 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004231 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004232 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004233 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004234 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004235
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004236 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4237 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4238 QuestionLoc);
4239 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4240 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004241
4242
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004243 // Handle block pointer types.
4244 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4245 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4246 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4247 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004248 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4249 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004250 return destType;
4251 }
4252 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004253 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004254 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004255 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004256 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4257 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4258 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004259 return LHSTy;
4260 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004261 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004262 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4263 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004264
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004265 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4266 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004267 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004268 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004269 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4270 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4271 // to get a consistent AST.
4272 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004273 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4274 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004275 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004276 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004277 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004278 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4279 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004280 return LHSTy;
4281 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004282
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004283 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4284 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4285 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004286 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4287 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004288
4289 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4290 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4291 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004292 QualType destPointee
4293 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004294 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004295 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4296 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4297 // Promote to void*.
4298 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004299 return destType;
4300 }
4301 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004302 QualType destPointee
4303 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004304 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004305 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004306 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004307 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004308 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004309 return destType;
4310 }
4311
4312 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4313 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4314 return LHSTy;
4315 }
4316 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4317 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4318 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4319 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4320 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4321 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4322 // to get a consistent AST.
4323 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004324 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4325 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004326 return incompatTy;
4327 }
4328 // The pointer types are compatible.
4329 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4330 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4331 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4332 // type.
4333 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4334 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004335 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4336 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004337 return LHSTy;
4338 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004339
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004340 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4341 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4342 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4343 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004344 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004345 return RHSTy;
4346 }
4347 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4348 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4349 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004350 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004351 return LHSTy;
4352 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004353
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004354 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004355 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4356 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004357 return QualType();
4358}
4359
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004360/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4361/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4362QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4363 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4364 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4365 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004366
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004367 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4368 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4369 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4370 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4371 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4372 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4373 return LHSTy;
4374 }
4375 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4376 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4377 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return RHSTy;
4379 }
4380 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4381 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4382 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4383 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4384 return LHSTy;
4385 }
4386 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4387 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4388 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4389 return RHSTy;
4390 }
4391 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4392 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4393 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4394 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4395 return LHSTy;
4396 }
4397 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4398 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4399 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4400 return RHSTy;
4401 }
4402 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4403 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004404
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004405 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4406 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4407 return LHSTy;
4408 }
4409 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4410 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4411 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004412
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004413 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4414 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4415 // type. This allows
4416 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4417 // where B is a subclass of A.
4418 //
4419 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4420 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4421 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4422 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004423
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004424 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4425 // It could return the composite type.
4426 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4427 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4428 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4429 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4430 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4431 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4432 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4433 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4434 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4435 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4436 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4437 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4438 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4439 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004440 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004441 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4442 ;
4443 else {
4444 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4445 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4446 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4447 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4448 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4449 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4450 return incompatTy;
4451 }
4452 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4453 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4454 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4455 return compositeType;
4456 }
4457 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4458 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4459 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4460 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4461 QualType destPointee
4462 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4463 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4464 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4465 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4466 // Promote to void*.
4467 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4468 return destType;
4469 }
4470 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4471 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4472 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4473 QualType destPointee
4474 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4475 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4476 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4477 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4478 // Promote to void*.
4479 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4480 return destType;
4481 }
4482 return QualType();
4483}
4484
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004485/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004486/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004487Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4488 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4489 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4490 ExprArg RHS) {
4491 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4492 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004493
4494 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4495 // was the condition.
4496 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4497 if (isLHSNull)
4498 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004499
4500 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004501 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004502 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004503 return ExprError();
4504
4505 Cond.release();
4506 LHS.release();
4507 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004508 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004509 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004510 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004511}
4512
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004513// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004514// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004515// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4516// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4517// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004518Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004519Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4520 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004521
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004522 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4523 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4524 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4525 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4526 return Compatible;
4527 }
4528
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004529 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004530 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4531 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004533 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004534 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4535 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004536
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004537 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
4539 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4540 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4541 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004542 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004543 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004544 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004545
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004546 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4547 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004548 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004549 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004550 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004551 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004553 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004554 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4555 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004556 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004557
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004558 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004559 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004560 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004561
4562 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004563 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4564 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004565 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004566 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004567 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004568 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4569 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4570 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4571 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4572 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4573 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004574 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004575 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004576 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004577 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004578
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004579 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004580 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004581 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004582 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004583
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004584 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4585 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4586 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4587 // warning can be disabled.
4588 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4589 return ConvTy;
4590 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4591 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004592
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004593 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4594 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4595 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4596 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4597 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4598 do {
4599 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4600 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004601
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004602 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4603 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4604 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004606 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004607 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004608 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004609
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004610 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004611 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004612 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004613 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004614}
4615
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004616/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4617/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4618/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4619// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004620Sema::AssignConvertType
4621Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004622 QualType rhsType) {
4623 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004624
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004625 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004626 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4627 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4630 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4631 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004633 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004634
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004635 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004636 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004637 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004639 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4640 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4641 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4642 }
4643 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004644 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004645 return ConvTy;
4646}
4647
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004648/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4649/// for assignment compatibility.
4650Sema::AssignConvertType
4651Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004652 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4653 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004654 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4655 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004656 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004657 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004658 }
4659 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4660 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004661 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4662 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004663 return IncompatiblePointer;
4664 return Compatible;
4665 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004666 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004667 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004668 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004669 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4670 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4671 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4672 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4673 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4674 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004675
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004676 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4677 return Compatible;
4678 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4679 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004680 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004681}
4682
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004683/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4684/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004685/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4686///
4687/// int a, *pint;
4688/// short *pshort;
4689/// struct foo *pfoo;
4690///
4691/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4692/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4693/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4694/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4695///
4696/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004697/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004698///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004699Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004700Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004701 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4702 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004703 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4704 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004705
4706 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004707 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004708
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004709 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4710 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4711 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4712 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4713 return Compatible;
4714 }
4715
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004716 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4717 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4718 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4719 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4720 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4721 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4722 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004723 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004724 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004725 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004726 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004727 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004728 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4729 // to the same ExtVector type.
4730 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4731 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4732 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4733 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4734 return Compatible;
4735 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004736
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004737 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004738 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004739 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004740 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004741 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4742 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004743 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004744 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004745 }
4746 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004747 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004748
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004749 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004750 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004751
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004752 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004753 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004754 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004755
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004756 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004757 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004758
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004759 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004760 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004761 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4762 return Compatible;
4763 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004764 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004765 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4766 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004767 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004768
4769 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004770 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004771 return Compatible;
4772 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004773 return Incompatible;
4774 }
4775
4776 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4777 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004778 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004779
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004780 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004781 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004782 return Compatible;
4783
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004784 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4785 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004786
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004787 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004788 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004789 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004790 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004791 return Incompatible;
4792 }
4793
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004794 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4795 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4796 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004797
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004798 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004799 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004800 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4801 return Compatible;
4802 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004803 }
4804 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004805 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004806 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004807 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004808 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4809 return Compatible;
4810 }
4811 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4812 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4813 return Compatible;
4814 return Incompatible;
4815 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004816 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004817 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004818 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4819 return Compatible;
4820
4821 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004822 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004823
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004824 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004825 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004826
4827 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004828 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004829 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004830 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004831 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004832 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4833 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4834 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4835 return Compatible;
4836
4837 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4838 return PointerToInt;
4839
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004840 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004841 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004842 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4843 return Compatible;
4844 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004845 }
4846 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004847 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004848 return Compatible;
4849 return Incompatible;
4850 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004851
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004852 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004853 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004854 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004855 }
4856 return Incompatible;
4857}
4858
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004859/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4860/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004861static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004862 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4863 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4864 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004865 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(SourceLocation(),
4866 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004867 SourceLocation());
4868 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4869 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4870
4871 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4872 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004873 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004874 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004875 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004876}
4877
4878Sema::AssignConvertType
4879Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4880 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4881
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004882 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004883 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4884 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004885 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004886 return Incompatible;
4887
4888 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4889 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4890 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4891 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004892 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4893 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004894 it != itend; ++it) {
4895 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4896 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4897 // 1) void pointer
4898 // 2) null pointer constant
4899 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004900 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004901 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004902 InitField = *it;
4903 break;
4904 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004905
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004906 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004907 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004908 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004909 InitField = *it;
4910 break;
4911 }
4912 }
4913
4914 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4915 == Compatible) {
4916 InitField = *it;
4917 break;
4918 }
4919 }
4920
4921 if (!InitField)
4922 return Incompatible;
4923
4924 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4925 return Compatible;
4926}
4927
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004928Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004929Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004930 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4931 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4932 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4933 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4934 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004935 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004936 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004937 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004938 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004939 }
4940
4941 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4942 // structures.
4943 }
4944
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004945 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4946 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004947 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4948 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004949 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004950 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004951 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004952 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004953 return Compatible;
4954 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004955
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004956 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004957 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004958 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004959 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004960 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004961 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004962 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004963 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004964
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004965 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4966 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004967
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004968 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4969 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004970 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4971 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4972 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4973 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004974 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004975 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4976 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004977 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004978}
4979
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004980QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004981 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004982 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004983 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004984 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004985}
4986
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004987QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004988 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004989 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004990 QualType lhsType =
4991 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4992 QualType rhsType =
4993 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004994
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004995 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004996 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004997 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004998
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004999 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5000 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005001 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5002 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005003 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5004 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005005 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005006 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005007 return lhsType->isExtVectorType() ? lhsType : rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005008 }
5009 }
5010 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005011
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005012 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5013 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5014 bool swapped = false;
5015 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5016 swapped = true;
5017 std::swap(rex, lex);
5018 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5019 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005020
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005021 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005022 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005023 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
5024 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
5025 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005026 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005027 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5028 return lhsType;
5029 }
5030 }
5031 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5032 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5033 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005034 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005035 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5036 return lhsType;
5037 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005038 }
5039 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005040
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005041 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005042 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005043 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005044 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005045 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005046}
5047
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005048QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5049 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005050 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005051 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005052
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005053 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005054
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005055 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5056 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5057 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005058
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005059 // Check for division by zero.
5060 if (isDiv &&
5061 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005062 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005063 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005064
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005065 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005066}
5067
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005068QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005069 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005070 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5071 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5072 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5073 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5074 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005075
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005076 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005077
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005078 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5079 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005080
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005081 // Check for remainder by zero.
5082 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005083 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5084 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005085
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005086 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005087}
5088
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005089QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005090 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5092 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5093 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5094 return compType;
5095 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005096
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005097 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005098
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005099 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005100 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5101 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5102 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005103 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005104 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005105
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005106 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5107 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005108 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005109 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5110
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005111 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005112
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005113 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005114 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005115
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005116 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5117 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005118 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5119 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005120 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005121 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005122 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005123
5124 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5125 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5126 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005127 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005128 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5129 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5130 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5131 return QualType();
5132 }
5133
5134 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5135 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5136 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005137 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005138 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005139 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005140 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005141 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5142 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005143 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5144 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005145 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005146 return QualType();
5147 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005148 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5149 if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5150 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5151 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5152 return QualType();
5153 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005154
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005155 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005156 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5157 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5158 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5159 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5160 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005161 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005162 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5163 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005164 return PExp->getType();
5165 }
5166 }
5167
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005168 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005169}
5170
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005171// C99 6.5.6
5172QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005173 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5174 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5175 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5176 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5177 return compType;
5178 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005179
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005180 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005181
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005182 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005183
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005184 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005185 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5186 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005187 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005188 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005189 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005190
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005191 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005192 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005193 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005194
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005195 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005196
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005197 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5198 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5199 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5200 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5201 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5202 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5203 return QualType();
5204 }
5205
5206 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5207 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5208 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5209 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5210 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005211 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005212 return QualType();
5213 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005214
5215 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5216 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5217 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005218 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005219 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005220 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005221 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005222 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005223
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005224 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5225 if (lpointee->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5226 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5227 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5228 return QualType();
5229 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005230
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005231 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005232 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5233 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5234 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5235 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5236 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5237 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005238 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005239 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5240
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005241 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005242 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005243 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005244
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005245 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005246 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005247 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005248
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005249 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5250 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5251 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5252 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5253 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5254 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5255 return QualType();
5256 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005257
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005258 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5259 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5260 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5261 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005262 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005263 return QualType();
5264 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005265
5266 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5267 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5268 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5269 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5270 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005271 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5272 << rex->getSourceRange()
5273 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005274 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005275
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005276 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5277 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5278 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5279 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5280 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5281 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5282 return QualType();
5283 }
5284 } else {
5285 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5286 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5287 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5288 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5289 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5290 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5291 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5292 return QualType();
5293 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005294 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005295
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005296 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5297 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5298 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5299 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5300 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005301 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005302 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005303
5304 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005305 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5306 }
5307 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005308
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005309 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005310}
5311
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005312// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005313QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005314 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005315 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5316 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005317 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005318
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005319 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5320 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5321 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5322
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005323 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5324 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005325 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5326 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5327 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5328 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5329 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005330 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005331 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005332 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005333
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005334 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005335
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005336 // Sanity-check shift operands
5337 llvm::APSInt Right;
5338 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005339 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5340 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005341 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005342 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5343 else {
5344 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5345 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5346 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5347 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5348 }
5349 }
5350
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005351 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005352 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005353}
5354
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005355// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005356QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005357 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5358 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5359
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005360 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005361 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005362 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005363
John McCalld1b47bf2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00005364 CheckSignCompare(lex, rex, Loc, &Opc);
John McCall45aa4552009-11-05 00:40:04 +00005365
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005366 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff30bf7712007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005367 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5368 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5369 else {
5370 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5371 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5372 }
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005373 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5374 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005375
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005376 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5377 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005378 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5379 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5380 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005381 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenek9ecede72009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005382 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005383 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5384 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5385 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5386 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenekb82dcd82009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005387 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5388 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005389 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005390
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005391 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5392 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5393 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5394 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005395
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005396 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5397 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005398 Expr *literalString = 0;
5399 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005400 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005401 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005402 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005403 literalString = lex;
5404 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005405 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5406 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005407 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005408 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005409 literalString = rex;
5410 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5411 }
5412
5413 if (literalString) {
5414 std::string resultComparison;
5415 switch (Opc) {
5416 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5417 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5418 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5419 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5420 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5421 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5422 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5423 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005424
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005425 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5426 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5427 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
5428 << literalString->getSourceRange()
5429 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(Loc), ", ")
5430 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(lex->getLocStart(),
5431 "strcmp(")
5432 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(
5433 PP.getLocForEndOfToken(rex->getLocEnd()),
5434 resultComparison));
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005435 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005436 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005437
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005438 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005439 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005440
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005441 if (isRelational) {
5442 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005443 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005444 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005445 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005446 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005447 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005448
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005449 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005450 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005451 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005452
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005453 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005454 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005455 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005456 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005457
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005458 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5459 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5460 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005461 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005462 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005463 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005464 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005465 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005466
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005467 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005468 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5469 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005470 if (!isRelational &&
5471 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5472 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5473 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5474 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5475 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5476 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5477 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5478 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5479 return ResultTy;
5480 }
5481 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005482 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5483 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5484 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5485 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5486 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5487 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005488 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005489 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005490 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
5491 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(lex, rex,
5492 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005493 if (T.isNull()) {
5494 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5495 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5496 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005497 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005498 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005499 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005500 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005501 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005502 }
5503
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005504 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5505 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005506 return ResultTy;
5507 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005508 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5509 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5510 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5511 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5512 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5513 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5514 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5515 }
5516 } else if (!isRelational &&
5517 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5518 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5519 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5520 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5521 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5522 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5523 }
5524 } else {
5525 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005526 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005527 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005528 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005529 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005530 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005531 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005532 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005533
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005534 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005535 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005536 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005537 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005538 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5539 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005540 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005541 return ResultTy;
5542 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005543 if (LHSIsNull &&
5544 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5545 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005546 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005547 return ResultTy;
5548 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005549
5550 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005551 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005552 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5553 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005554 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5555 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5556 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5557 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5558 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5559 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5560 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5561 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005562 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005563 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
5564 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(lex, rex,
5565 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005566 if (T.isNull()) {
5567 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005568 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005569 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005570 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005571 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005572 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005573 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005574 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005575 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005576
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005577 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5578 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005579 return ResultTy;
5580 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005581
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005582 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005583 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5584 return ResultTy;
5585 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005586
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005587 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005588 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005589 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5590 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005591
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005592 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005593 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005594 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005595 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005596 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005597 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005598 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005599 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005600 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005601 if (!isRelational
5602 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5603 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005604 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005605 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005606 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005607 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005608 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5609 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5610 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005611 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005612 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005613 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005614 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005615
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005616 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005617 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005618 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5619 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005620 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005621 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005622 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005623 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005624
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005625 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5626 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005627 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005628 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005629 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005630 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005631 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005632 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005633 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005634 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005635 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5636 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005637 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005638 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005639 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005640 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005641 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005642 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5643 if (RHSIsNull) {
5644 if (isRelational)
5645 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5646 } else if (isRelational)
5647 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5648 else
5649 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005650
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005651 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005652 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005653 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005654 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005655 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005656 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005657 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005658 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005659 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5660 if (LHSIsNull) {
5661 if (isRelational)
5662 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5663 } else if (isRelational)
5664 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5665 else
5666 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005667
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005668 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005669 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005670 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005671 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005672 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005673 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005674 }
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005675 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005676 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5677 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005678 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005679 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005680 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005681 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5682 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005683 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005684 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005685 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005686 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005687}
5688
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005689/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005690/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005691/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5692/// types.
5693QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005694 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005695 bool isRelational) {
5696 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5697 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005698 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005699 if (vType.isNull())
5700 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005701
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005702 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5703 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005704
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005705 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5706 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5707 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5708 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5709 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5710 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5711 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005712 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005713 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005714
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005715 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5716 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5717 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005718 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005719 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005720
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005721 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5722 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5723 // elements for floating point vectors.
5724 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5725 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005726
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005727 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005728 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005729 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005730 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005731 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005732 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5733
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005734 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005735 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005736 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5737}
5738
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005739inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005740 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff3e5e5562007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005741 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005742 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005743
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005744 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005745
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005746 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005747 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005748 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005749}
5750
5751inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005752 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005753 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5754 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5755 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005756
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005757 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5758 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005759
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005760 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005761 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005762
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005763 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5764 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5765 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5766 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5767 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5768 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5769 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005770
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005771 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005772 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005773 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005774
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005775 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5776 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5777 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5778 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005779
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005780 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005781 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005782 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005783
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005784 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5785 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5786 // The result is a bool.
5787 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005788}
5789
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005790/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5791/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5792/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5793///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005794static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005795 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5796 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5797 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5798 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005799 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005800 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5801 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5802 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5803 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005804 }
5805 }
5806 return false;
5807}
5808
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005809/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5810/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5811static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005812 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005813 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005814 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005815 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5816 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005817 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5818 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005819
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005820 unsigned Diag = 0;
5821 bool NeedType = false;
5822 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005823 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005824 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005825 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5826 NeedType = true;
5827 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005828 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005829 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5830 NeedType = true;
5831 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005832 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005833 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5834 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005835 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5836 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005837 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005838 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5839 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005840 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5841 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005842 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5843 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005844 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005845 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005846 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005847 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005848 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5849 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005850 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005851 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5852 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005853 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5854 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5855 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005856 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5857 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5858 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005859 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5860 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5861 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005862 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005863
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005864 SourceRange Assign;
5865 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5866 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005867 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005868 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005869 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005871 return true;
5872}
5873
5874
5875
5876// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005877QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5878 SourceLocation Loc,
5879 QualType CompoundType) {
5880 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5881 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005882 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005883
5884 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5885 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005886
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005887 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005888 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005889 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005890 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005891 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5892 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5893 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005894 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005895 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005896 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005897 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005898
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005899 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5900 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5901 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005902 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005903 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5904 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5905 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5906 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5907 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005908 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005909 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005910 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5911 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5912 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005913 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5914 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005915 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5916 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5917 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005918 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005919 }
5920 } else {
5921 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005922 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005923 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005924
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005925 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005926 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005927 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005928
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005929 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5930 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005931 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005932 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5933 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005934 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005935 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005936 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005937}
5938
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005939// C99 6.5.17
5940QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005941 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005942 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5943 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5944 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005945
5946 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5947 // incomplete in C++).
5948
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005949 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005950}
5951
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005952/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5953/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005954QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
5955 bool isInc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005956 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5957 return Context.DependentTy;
5958
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005959 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5960 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005961
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005962 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5963 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5964 if (!isInc) {
5965 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5966 return QualType();
5967 }
5968 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5969 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5970 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005971 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005972 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5973 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005974
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005975 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005976 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005977 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5978 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5979 << Op->getSourceRange();
5980 return QualType();
5981 }
5982
5983 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005984 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005985 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005986 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5987 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5988 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5989 return QualType();
5990 }
5991
5992 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005993 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005994 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005995 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005996 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005997 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005998 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005999 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
6000 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
6001 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6002 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6003 return QualType();
6004 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006005 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006006 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006008 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006009 } else {
6010 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006011 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006012 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006013 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006014 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006015 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006016 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006017 return QualType();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006018 return ResType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006019}
6020
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006021/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006022/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006023/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6024/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6025/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6026/// - &(x) => x
6027/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6028/// - &s.xx => s
6029/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6030/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6031/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6032/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006033static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006034 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006035 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006036 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006037 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006038 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6039 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6040 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006041 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006042 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006043 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006044 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006045 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006046 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6047 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006048 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6049 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6050 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6051 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6052 }
6053 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006054 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006055 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6056 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006057
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006058 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006059 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6060 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6061 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6062 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6063 default:
6064 return 0;
6065 }
6066 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006067 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006068 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006069 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006070 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6071 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006072 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006073 default:
6074 return 0;
6075 }
6076}
6077
6078/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006079/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006080/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006081/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006082/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006083/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006084/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006085QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006086 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6087 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6088
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006089 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6090 return Context.DependentTy;
6091
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006092 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6093 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6094 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6095 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6096 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6097 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6098 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6099 }
6100 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6101 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6102 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006103 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006104 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006105
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006106 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6107 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6108 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6109 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6110 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6111 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6112 // branch of the if, below.
6113 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6114 << dcl;
6115 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6116
6117 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6118 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6119 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6120 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006121 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6122 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6123 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6124 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6125 if (isSFINAEContext())
6126 return QualType();
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006127 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006128 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006129 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006130 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006131 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006132 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6133 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006134 return QualType();
6135 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006136 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006137 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6138 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6139 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006140 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006141 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006142 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006143 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006144 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006145 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006146 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6147 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6148 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6149 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6150 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006151 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6152 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006153 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6154 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006155 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6156 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006157 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006158 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006159 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6160 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6161 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006162 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6163 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006164 return QualType();
6165 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006166 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006167 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006168 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006169 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006170 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6171 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006172 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006173 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006174 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6175 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006176 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006177 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6178 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6179 return QualType();
6180 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006181
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006182 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6183 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006184 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006185 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006186 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006187 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006188 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006189 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6190 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006191 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6192 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6193 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006194 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006195 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006196
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006197 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6198 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6199 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6200 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6201 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6202 }
6203
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006204 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
6205 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6206}
6207
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006208QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006209 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6210 return Context.DependentTy;
6211
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006212 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6213 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006214
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006215 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6216 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6217 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6218 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006219 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006220 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006221
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006222 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanian16b10372009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006223 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006224
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006225 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006226 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006227 return QualType();
6228}
6229
6230static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6231 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6232 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6233 switch (Kind) {
6234 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006235 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6236 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006237 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6238 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6239 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6240 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6241 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6242 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6243 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6244 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6245 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6246 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6247 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6248 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6249 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6250 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6251 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6252 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6253 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6254 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6255 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6256 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6257 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6258 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6259 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6260 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6261 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6262 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6263 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6264 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6265 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6266 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6267 }
6268 return Opc;
6269}
6270
6271static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6272 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6273 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6274 switch (Kind) {
6275 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6276 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6277 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6278 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6279 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6280 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6281 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6282 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6283 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006284 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6285 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6286 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6287 }
6288 return Opc;
6289}
6290
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006291/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6292/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6293/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006294Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6295 unsigned Op,
6296 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006297 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006298 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006299 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6300 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6301 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006302
6303 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006304 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6305 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6306 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006307 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6308 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6309 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6310 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6311 break;
6312 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006313 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006314 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6315 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006316 break;
6317 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6318 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6319 break;
6320 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6321 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6322 break;
6323 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6324 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6325 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006326 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006327 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6328 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6329 break;
6330 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6331 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6332 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6333 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006334 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006335 break;
6336 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6337 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006338 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006339 break;
6340 case BinaryOperator::And:
6341 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6342 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6343 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6344 break;
6345 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6346 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6347 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6348 break;
6349 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6350 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006351 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6352 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006353 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6354 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6355 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006356 break;
6357 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006358 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6359 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6360 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6361 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006362 break;
6363 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006364 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6365 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6366 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006367 break;
6368 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006369 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6370 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6371 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006372 break;
6373 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6374 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006375 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6376 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6377 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6378 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006379 break;
6380 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6381 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6382 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006383 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6384 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6385 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6386 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006387 break;
6388 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6389 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6390 break;
6391 }
6392 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006393 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006394 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006395 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6396 else
6397 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006398 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6399 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006400}
6401
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006402/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6403/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006404static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6405 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006406 SourceRange ParenRange,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006407 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondPD,
6408 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006409 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
6410 if (!ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6411 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6412 // warning/error and return.
6413 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6414 return;
6415 }
6416
6417 Self.Diag(Loc, PD)
6418 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6419 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006420
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006421 if (!SecondPD.getDiagID())
6422 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006423
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006424 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6425 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6426 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6427 // warning/error and return.
6428 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondPD);
6429 return;
6430 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006431
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006432 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondPD)
6433 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6434 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006435}
6436
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006437/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6438/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6439/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6440/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006441static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6442 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006443 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6444 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6445 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6446 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006447 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006448 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006449 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6450
6451 // Subs are not binary operators.
6452 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6453 return;
6454
6455 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6456 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006457 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6458 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006459 return;
6460
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006461 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006462 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006463 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006464 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6465 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006466 lhs->getSourceRange(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006467 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006468 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006469 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()));
6470 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006471 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006472 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006473 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6474 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006475 rhs->getSourceRange(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006476 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006477 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006478 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()));
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006479}
6480
6481/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6482/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6483/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6484static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6485 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006486 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006487 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6488}
6489
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006490// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006491Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6492 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6493 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006494 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006495 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006496
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006497 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6498 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006499
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006500 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6501 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6502
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006503 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6504}
6505
6506Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6507 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6508 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006509 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006510 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006511 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6512 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6513 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6514 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6515 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006516 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006517 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006518 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6519 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6520 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006521
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006522 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6523 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006524 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006525 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006526
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006527 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006528 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006529}
6530
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006531Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006532 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006533 ExprArg InputArg) {
6534 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006535
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006536 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006537 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006538 QualType resultType;
6539 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006540 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6541 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6542 break;
6543
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006544 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6545 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006546 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6547 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006548 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006549 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6550 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006551 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006552 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006553 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6554 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006555 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006556 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006557 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6558 break;
6559 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6560 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006561 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6562 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006563 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6564 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006565 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6566 break;
6567 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6568 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6569 break;
6570 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6571 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6572 resultType->isPointerType())
6573 break;
6574
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006575 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6576 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006577 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006578 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6579 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006580 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6581 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006582 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6583 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6584 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006585 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006586 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006587 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006588 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6589 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006590 break;
6591 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6592 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006593 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006594 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006595 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6596 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006597 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006598 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6599 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006600 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006601 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6602 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006603 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006604 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006605 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006606 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006607 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006608 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006609 resultType = Input->getType();
6610 break;
6611 }
6612 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006613 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006614
6615 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006616 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006617}
6618
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006619Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6620 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6621 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006622 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006623 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6624 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006625 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6626 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6627 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6628 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006629 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006630 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006631 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6632 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6633 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006634
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006635 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6636 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006637
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006638 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6639}
6640
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006641// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6642Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6643 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6644 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6645}
6646
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006647/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006648Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6649 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6650 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006651 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006652 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006653
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006654 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6655 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006656 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006657 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006658
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006659 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006660 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6661 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006662}
6663
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006664Sema::OwningExprResult
6665Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6666 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6667 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006668 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6669 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6670
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006671 bool isFileScope
6672 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006673 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006674 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006675
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006676 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6677 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6678 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006679
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006680 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6681 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6682 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006683
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006684 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6685 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6686 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6687 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6688 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006689
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006690 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006691 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006692 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006693
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006694 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6695 // expressions are not lvalues.
6696
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006697 substmt.release();
6698 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006699}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006700
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006701Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6702 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6703 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6704 TypeTy *argty,
6705 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6706 unsigned NumComponents,
6707 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6708 // FIXME: This function leaks all expressions in the offset components on
6709 // error.
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006710 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6711 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006712 assert(!ArgTy.isNull() && "Missing type argument!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006713
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006714 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6715
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006716 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6717 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6718 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006719 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006720 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006721
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006722 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6723 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
Douglas Gregor4fdf1fa2009-03-11 16:48:53 +00006724
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006725 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6726 // the offsetof designators.
6727 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6728 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006729 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006730 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
Eli Friedman1d242592009-01-26 01:33:06 +00006731
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006732 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6733 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006734 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6735 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006736 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006737 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6738 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006739
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006740 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedmanc0d600c2009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006741 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006742
John McCalld00f2002009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006743 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6744 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6745 return ExprError();
6746
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006747 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6748 // leaks like a sieve.
6749 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6750 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6751 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6752 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6753 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6754 if (!AT) {
6755 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006756 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6757 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006758 }
6759
6760 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
6761
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006762 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6763 // expression.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006764 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006765
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006766 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6767 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006768 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006769 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006770 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006771 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006772 << Idx->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006773
6774 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6775 OC.LocEnd);
6776 continue;
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006777 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006778
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006779 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006780 if (!RC) {
6781 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006782 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6783 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006784 }
Chris Lattner704fe352007-08-30 17:59:59 +00006785
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006786 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6787 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006788 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006789 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6790 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6791 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6792 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6793 << Res->getType()))
6794 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006795 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006796
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006797 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6798 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
John McCallf36e02d2009-10-09 21:13:30 +00006799
John McCall1bcee0a2009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006800 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006801 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006802 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregor3f093272009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006803 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6804 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006805
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006806 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6807 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006808 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006809 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
John McCall09b6d0e2009-11-11 03:23:23 +00006810 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006811 } else {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006812 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6813 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006814 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6815 // doesn't matter here.
6816 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
6817 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
6818 }
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006819 }
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006820 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006821
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006822 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6823 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006824}
6825
6826
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006827Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6828 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6829 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006830 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6831 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6832 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006833
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006834 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006835
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006836 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6837 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6838 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6839 return ExprError();
6840 }
6841
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006842 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6843 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006844}
6845
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006846Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6847 ExprArg cond,
6848 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6849 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6850 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6851 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6852 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006853
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006854 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6855
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006856 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006857 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006858 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006859 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006860 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006861 } else {
6862 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6863 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6864 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6865 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006866 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6867 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6868 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006869
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006870 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6871 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006872 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6873 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006874 }
6875
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006876 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6877 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006878 resType, RPLoc,
6879 resType->isDependentType(),
6880 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006881}
6882
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006883//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6884// Clang Extensions.
6885//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6886
6887/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006888void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006889 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6890 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6891 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6892 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006893}
6894
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006895void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006896 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006897 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006898
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006899 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6900 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006901 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006902 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
6903
Mike Stump4eeab842009-04-28 01:10:27 +00006904 if (T->isArrayType()) {
6905 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6906 diag::err_block_returns_array);
6907 return;
6908 }
6909
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006910 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
6911 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindola264ba482010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006912 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
6913 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006914
6915 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
6916 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006917 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006918 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006919 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian3bba33d2009-05-15 21:18:04 +00006920 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006921 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
6922 }
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006923 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006924
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006925 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
6926 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
6927 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6928 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
6929 return;
6930 }
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006931
6932 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006933 return;
6934 }
6935
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006936 // Analyze arguments to block.
6937 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
6938 "Not a function declarator!");
6939 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006940
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006941 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
6942 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006943
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006944 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
6945 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
6946 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
6947 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattnerb28317a2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00006948 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
6949 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006950 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006951 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006952 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00006953 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
6954 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
6955 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
6956 !Param->isImplicit() &&
6957 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
6958 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6959 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
6960 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
6961 }
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006962 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006963 }
Douglas Gregor838db382010-02-11 01:19:42 +00006964 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006965 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahaniand66f22d2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00006966 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006967 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006968
6969 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
6970 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
6971
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006972 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00006973 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
6974 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
6975
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006976 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006977 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
6978 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
6979 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
6980
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006981 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006982 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00006983 }
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006984
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006985 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006986 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006987 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006988 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian3bba33d2009-05-15 21:18:04 +00006989 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian2f7c3922009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006990 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
6991 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006992
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006993 // Analyze the return type.
6994 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006995 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006996
Chris Lattner9097af12009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006997 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
6998 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
6999 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7000 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7001 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007002 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007003}
7004
7005/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7006/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7007void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007008 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007009 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007010 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007011 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007012}
7013
7014/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7015/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007016Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7017 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007018 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7019 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7020 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007021
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007022 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007023
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007024 PopDeclContext();
7025
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007026 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007027 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7028 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007029
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007030 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7031 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7032 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007033
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007034 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007035 QualType BlockTy;
7036 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007037 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola425ef722010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007038 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007039 else
Jay Foadbeaaccd2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007040 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007041 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola425ef722010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007042 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007043
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007044 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007045 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007046 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007047
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007048 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007049 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007050 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007051
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007052 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007053
7054 bool Good = true;
7055 // Check goto/label use.
7056 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7057 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7058 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7059
7060 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7061 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7062 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7063 continue;
7064
7065 // Emit error.
7066 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7067 Good = false;
7068 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007069 if (!Good) {
7070 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007071 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007072 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007073
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007074 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007075 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7076 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7077 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007078
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007079 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7080 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007081 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007082 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007083}
7084
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007085Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7086 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7087 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007088 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007089 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7090 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007091
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007092 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007093
7094 // Get the va_list type
7095 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007096 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7097 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7098 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7099 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007100 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007101 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7102 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7103 } else {
7104 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7105 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007106 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007107 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007108 return ExprError();
7109 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007110
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007111 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7112 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007113 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7114 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007115 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007116 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007117
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007118 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007119 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007120
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007121 expr.release();
7122 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7123 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007124}
7125
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007126Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007127 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7128 // pointers on the target.
7129 QualType Ty;
7130 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7131 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7132 else
7133 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7134
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007135 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007136}
7137
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007138static void
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007139MakeObjCStringLiteralCodeModificationHint(Sema& SemaRef,
7140 QualType DstType,
7141 Expr *SrcExpr,
7142 CodeModificationHint &Hint) {
7143 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7144 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007145
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007146 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7147 if (!PT)
7148 return;
7149
7150 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7151 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7152 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7153 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7154 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7155 return;
7156 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007157
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007158 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7159 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7160 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7161 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007162
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007163 Hint = CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
7164}
7165
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007166bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7167 SourceLocation Loc,
7168 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007169 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action) {
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007170 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7171 bool isInvalid = false;
7172 unsigned DiagKind;
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007173 CodeModificationHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007174
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007175 switch (ConvTy) {
7176 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7177 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007178 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007179 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7180 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007181 case IntToPointer:
7182 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7183 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007184 case IncompatiblePointer:
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007185 MakeObjCStringLiteralCodeModificationHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007186 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7187 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007188 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7189 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7190 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007191 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7192 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7193 break;
7194 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007195 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7196 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7197 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7198 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7199 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7200 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7201 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7202 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7203 // C++ semantics.
7204 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7205 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7206 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007207 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7208 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007209 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007210 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007211 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007212 case IntToBlockPointer:
7213 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7214 break;
7215 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007216 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007217 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007218 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007219 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007220 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7221 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7222 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007223 case IncompatibleVectors:
7224 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7225 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007226 case Incompatible:
7227 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7228 isInvalid = true;
7229 break;
7230 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007231
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007232 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << DstType << SrcType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007233 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007234 return isInvalid;
7235}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007236
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007237bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007238 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7239 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7240 if (Result)
7241 *Result = ICEResult;
7242 return false;
7243 }
7244
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007245 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7246
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007247 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007248 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7249 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7250
7251 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7252 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7253 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7254 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7255 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7256 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7257 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007258
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007259 return true;
7260 }
7261
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007262 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7263 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007264
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007265 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7266 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7267 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007268
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007269 if (Result)
7270 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7271 return false;
7272}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007273
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007274void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007275Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007276 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7277 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007278}
7279
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007280void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007281Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7282 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7283 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7284 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007285
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007286 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7287 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7288 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7289 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7290 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007291 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007292 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7293 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7294 I != IEnd; ++I)
7295 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7296 }
7297
7298 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7299 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7300 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7301 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7302 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7303 I != IEnd; ++I)
7304 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7305 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007306 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007307
7308 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7309 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7310 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7311 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007312 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007313 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7314 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7315 ExprTemporaries.end());
7316
7317 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7318 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007319}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007320
7321/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7322///
7323/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7324/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7325/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7326/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7327///
7328/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7329///
7330/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7331void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7332 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007333
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007334 if (D->isUsed())
7335 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007336
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007337 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7338 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7339 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7340 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007341 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007342 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()))
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007343 D->setUsed(true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007344
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007345 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7346 // an instantiation.
7347 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7348 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007349
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007350 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007351 case Unevaluated:
7352 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7353 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007354
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007355 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7356 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7357 // "used"; handle this below.
7358 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007359
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007360 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7361 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7362 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7363 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007364 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007365 return;
7366 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007367
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007368 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007369 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007370 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007371 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7372 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7373 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007374 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007375 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007376 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7377 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7378 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007379
Anders Carlssond6a637f2009-12-07 08:24:59 +00007380 MaybeMarkVirtualMembersReferenced(Loc, Constructor);
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007381 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7382 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7383 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007384
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007385 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7386 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7387 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7388 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
7389 DefineImplicitOverloadedAssign(Loc, MethodDecl);
7390 }
7391 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007392 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007393 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007394 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007395 if (!Function->getBody() && Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007396 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7397 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7398 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7399 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7400 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007401 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007402 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007403 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007404 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007405 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7406 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7407 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007408 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007409 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007410 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7411 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007412
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007413 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7414 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7415 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7416 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7417 Loc));
7418 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007419 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007420 Loc));
7421 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007422 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007423
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007424 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007425 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007426
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007427 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007428 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007429
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007430 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007431 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007432 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007433 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7434 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7435 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7436 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7437 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7438 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7439 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7440 }
7441 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007442
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007443 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007444
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007445 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007446 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007447 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007448}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007449
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007450/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7451/// of the program being compiled.
7452///
7453/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007454/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007455/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7456/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7457/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7458/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007459/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007460/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007461///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007462/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7463/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7464/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7465/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007466bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007467 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7468 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7469 case Unevaluated:
7470 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7471 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007472
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007473 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7474 Diag(Loc, PD);
7475 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007476
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007477 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7478 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7479 break;
7480 }
7481
7482 return false;
7483}
7484
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007485bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7486 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7487 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7488 return false;
7489
7490 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7491 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7492 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7493 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007494
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007495 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007496 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007497 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7498 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007499 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007500 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7501 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7502 return true;
7503
7504 return false;
7505}
7506
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007507// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7508// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7509void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7510 SourceLocation Loc;
7511
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007512 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7513
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007514 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7515 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7516 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7517 return;
7518
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007519 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7520 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7521 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7522 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7523
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007524 // self = [<foo> init...]
7525 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7526 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7527 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7528
7529 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7530 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7531 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7532 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7533 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007534
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007535 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7536 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7537 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7538 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7539 return;
7540
7541 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7542 } else {
7543 // Not an assignment.
7544 return;
7545 }
7546
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007547 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007548 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007549
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007550 Diag(Loc, diagnostic)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007551 << E->getSourceRange()
7552 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7553 << CodeModificationHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007554 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
7555 << CodeModificationHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007556}
7557
7558bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7559 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7560
7561 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007562 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007563
7564 QualType T = E->getType();
7565
7566 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7567 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7568 return true;
7569 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7570 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7571 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7572 return true;
7573 }
7574 }
7575
7576 return false;
7577}